xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 1c0bd035)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2021 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
22 #include <net/codel.h>
23 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
24 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
25 
26 /**
27  * DOC: Introduction
28  *
29  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
30  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
31  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
32  * drivers.
33  */
34 
35 /**
36  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
37  *
38  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
39  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
40  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
41  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
42  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
43  * tasklet function.
44  *
45  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
46  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
47  */
48 
49 /**
50  * DOC: Warning
51  *
52  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
53  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
54  */
55 
56 /**
57  * DOC: Frame format
58  *
59  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
60  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
61  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
62  * hardware.
63  *
64  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
65  *
66  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
67  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
68  *
69  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
70  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
71  */
72 
73 /**
74  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
75  *
76  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
77  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
78  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
79  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
80  *
81  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
82  * suspend.
83  *
84  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
85  *
86  */
87 
88 /**
89  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
90  *
91  * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
92  * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
93  * between different stations/interfaces.
94  * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
95  * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
96  * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
97  *
98  * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
99  * driver operation.
100  *
101  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104  *
105  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107  *
108  * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame from a
109  * txq, it calls ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a
110  * queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
111  *
112  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
113  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
114  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
115  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
116  * ieee80211_return_txq().
117  *
118  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
119  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
120  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
121  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
122  * .release_buffered_frames().
123  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
124  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
125  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
126  */
127 
128 struct device;
129 
130 /**
131  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
132  *
133  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
134  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
135  */
136 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
137 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
138 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
139 };
140 
141 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
142 
143 /**
144  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
145  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
146  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
147  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
148  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
149  */
150 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
151 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
152 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
153 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
154 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
155 };
156 
157 /**
158  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
159  *
160  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
161  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
162  *
163  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
164  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
165  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
166  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
167  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
168  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
169  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
170  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
171  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
172  */
173 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
174 	u16 txop;
175 	u16 cw_min;
176 	u16 cw_max;
177 	u8 aifs;
178 	bool acm;
179 	bool uapsd;
180 	bool mu_edca;
181 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
182 };
183 
184 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
185 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
186 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
187 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
188 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
189 };
190 
191 /**
192  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
193  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
194  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
195  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
196  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
197  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
198  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
199  */
200 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
201 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
202 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
203 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
204 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
205 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
206 };
207 
208 /**
209  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
210  *
211  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
212  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
213  *
214  * @def: the channel definition
215  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
216  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
217  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
218  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
219  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
220  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
221  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
222  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
223  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
224  */
225 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
226 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
227 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
228 
229 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
230 
231 	bool radar_enabled;
232 
233 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
234 };
235 
236 /**
237  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
238  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
239  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
240  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
241  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
242  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
243  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
244  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
245  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
246  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
247  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
248  *      for changes/removal.)
249  */
250 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
251 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
252 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
253 };
254 
255 /**
256  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
257  *
258  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
259  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
260  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
261  * done.
262  *
263  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
264  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
265  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
266  */
267 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
268 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
269 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
270 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
275  *
276  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
277  * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
278  *
279  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
280  *	also implies a change in the AID.
281  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
282  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
283  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
284  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
285  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
286  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
287  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
288  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
289  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
290  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
291  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
292  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
293  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
294  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
295  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
296  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
297  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
298  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
300  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
304  *	changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
306  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
308  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
309  *	context had been assigned.
310  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
312  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
313  *	keep alive) changed.
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
316  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
317  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
322  *	status changed.
323  *
324  */
325 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
326 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
327 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
328 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
329 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
330 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
331 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
332 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
333 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
334 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
335 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
336 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
337 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
338 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
339 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
340 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
341 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
342 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
343 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
344 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
345 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
346 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
358 
359 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
360 };
361 
362 /*
363  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
364  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
365  * filtering will be disabled.
366  */
367 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
368 
369 /**
370  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
371  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
372  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
373  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
374  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
375  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
376  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
377  */
378 enum ieee80211_event_type {
379 	RSSI_EVENT,
380 	MLME_EVENT,
381 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
382 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
383 };
384 
385 /**
386  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
387  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
388  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
389  */
390 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
391 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
392 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
393 };
394 
395 /**
396  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
397  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
398  */
399 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
400 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
401 };
402 
403 /**
404  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
405  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
406  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
407  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
408  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
409  */
410 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
411 	AUTH_EVENT,
412 	ASSOC_EVENT,
413 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
414 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
415 };
416 
417 /**
418  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
419  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
420  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
421  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
422  */
423 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
424 	MLME_SUCCESS,
425 	MLME_DENIED,
426 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
427 };
428 
429 /**
430  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
431  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
432  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
433  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
434  */
435 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
436 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
437 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
438 	u16 reason;
439 };
440 
441 /**
442  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
443  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
444  * @tid: the tid
445  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
446  */
447 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
448 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
449 	u16 tid;
450 	u16 ssn;
451 };
452 
453 /**
454  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
455  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
456  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
457  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
458  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
459  * @u:union holding the fields above
460  */
461 struct ieee80211_event {
462 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
463 	union {
464 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
465 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
466 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
467 	} u;
468 };
469 
470 /**
471  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
472  *
473  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
474  *
475  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
476  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
477  */
478 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
479 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
480 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
481 };
482 
483 /**
484  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
485  *
486  * @lci: LCI subelement content
487  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
488  * @lci_len: LCI data length
489  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
490  */
491 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
492 	const u8 *lci;
493 	const u8 *civicloc;
494 	size_t lci_len;
495 	size_t civicloc_len;
496 };
497 
498 /**
499  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
500  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
501  *
502  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
503  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
504  */
505 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
506 	u32 min_interval;
507 	u32 max_interval;
508 };
509 
510 /**
511  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
512  *
513  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
514  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
515  *
516  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
517  * @multi_sta_back_32bit: supports BA bitmap of 32-bits in Multi-STA BACK
518  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
519  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
520  *	ACK, BACK or both
521  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
522  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
523  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
524  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
525  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
526  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
527  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
528  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
529  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
530  * @assoc: association status
531  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
532  *	or not
533  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
534  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
535  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
536  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
537  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
538  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
539  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
540  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
541  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
542  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
543  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
544  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
545  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
546  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
547  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
548  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
549  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
550  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
551  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
552  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
553  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
554  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
555  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
556  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
557  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
558  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
559  *	the current band.
560  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
561  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
562  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
563  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
564  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
565  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
566  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
567  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
568  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
569  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
570  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
571  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
572  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
573  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
574  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
575  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
576  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
577  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
578  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
579  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
580  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
581  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
582  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
583  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
584  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
585  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
586  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
587  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
588  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
589  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
590  *	your driver/device needs to do.
591  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
592  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
593  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
594  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
595  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
596  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
597  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
598  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
599  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
600  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
601  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
602  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
603  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
604  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
605  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
606  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
607  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
608  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
609  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
610  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
611  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
612  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
613  *	station.
614  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
615  *	responder functionality.
616  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
617  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
618  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
619  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
620  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
621  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
622  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
623  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
624  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
625  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
626  *	connected to (STA)
627  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
628  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
629  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
630  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
631  *	interval.
632  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
633  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
634  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
635  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
636  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
637  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
638  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
639  */
640 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
641 	const u8 *bssid;
642 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
643 	bool uora_exists;
644 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
645 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
646 	bool he_support;
647 	bool twt_requester;
648 	bool twt_responder;
649 	bool twt_protected;
650 	bool twt_broadcast;
651 	/* association related data */
652 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
653 	bool ibss_creator;
654 	u16 aid;
655 	/* erp related data */
656 	bool use_cts_prot;
657 	bool use_short_preamble;
658 	bool use_short_slot;
659 	bool enable_beacon;
660 	u8 dtim_period;
661 	u16 beacon_int;
662 	u16 assoc_capability;
663 	u64 sync_tsf;
664 	u32 sync_device_ts;
665 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
666 	u32 basic_rates;
667 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
668 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
669 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
670 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
671 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
672 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
673 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
674 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
675 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
676 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
677 	int arp_addr_cnt;
678 	bool qos;
679 	bool idle;
680 	bool ps;
681 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
682 	size_t ssid_len;
683 	bool hidden_ssid;
684 	int txpower;
685 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
686 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
687 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
688 	u16 max_idle_period;
689 	bool protected_keep_alive;
690 	bool ftm_responder;
691 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
692 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
693 	bool nontransmitted;
694 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
695 	u8 bssid_index;
696 	u8 bssid_indicator;
697 	bool ema_ap;
698 	u8 profile_periodicity;
699 	struct {
700 		u32 params;
701 		u16 nss_set;
702 	} he_oper;
703 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
704 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
705 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
706 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
707 	bool s1g;
708 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
709 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
710 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
711 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
712 	u8 pwr_reduction;
713 };
714 
715 /**
716  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
717  *
718  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
719  *
720  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
721  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
722  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
723  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
724  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
725  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
726  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
727  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
728  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
729  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
730  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
731  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
732  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
733  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
734  *	station
735  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
736  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
737  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
738  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
739  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
740  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
741  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
742  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
743  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
744  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
745  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
746  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
747  *	hardware queue.
748  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
749  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
750  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
751  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
752  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
753  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
754  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
755  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
756  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
757  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
758  *	off-channel operation.
759  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
760  *	(header conversion)
761  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
762  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
763  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
764  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
765  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
766  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
767  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
768  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
769  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
770  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
771  *	queue gets full.
772  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
773  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
774  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
775  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
776  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
777  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
778  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
779  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
780  *	status to user space)
781  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
782  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
783  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
784  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
785  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
786  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
787  *	handled properly by the device.
788  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
789  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
790  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
791  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
792  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
793  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
794  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
795  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
796  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
797  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
798  *	PS-Poll responses.
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
800  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
801  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
802  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
803  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
804  *	monitor injection).
805  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
806  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
807  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
808  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
809  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
810  *
811  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
812  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
813  */
814 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
815 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
816 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
817 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
818 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
819 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
820 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
821 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
822 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
823 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
824 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
825 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
826 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
827 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
828 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
829 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
830 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
831 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
832 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
833 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
834 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
835 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
836 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
837 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
838 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
839 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
840 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
841 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
842 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
843 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
844 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
845 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
846 };
847 
848 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
849 
850 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
851 
852 /**
853  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
854  *
855  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
856  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
857  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
858  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
859  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
860  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
861  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
862  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
863  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
864  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
865  *	it can be sent out.
866  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
867  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
868  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
869  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
870  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
871  *
872  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
873  */
874 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
875 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
876 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
877 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
878 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
879 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
880 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
881 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
884 };
885 
886 /*
887  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
888  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
889  */
890 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
891 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
892 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
893 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
894 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
895 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
896 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
897 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
898 
899 /**
900  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
901  *	Rate Control algorithm.
902  *
903  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
904  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
905  *
906  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
907  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
908  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
909  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
910  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
911  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
912  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
913  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
914  *	Greenfield mode.
915  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
916  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
917  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
918  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
920  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
921  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
922  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
923  */
924 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
925 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
926 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
927 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
928 
929 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
930 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
931 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
932 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
933 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
934 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
935 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
936 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
937 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
938 };
939 
940 
941 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
942 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
943 
944 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
945 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
946 
947 /* maximum number of rate stages */
948 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
949 
950 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
951 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
952 
953 /**
954  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
955  *
956  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
957  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
958  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
959  *
960  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
961  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
962  *
963  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
964  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
965  *
966  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
967  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
968  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
969  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
970  * information::
971  *
972  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
973  *
974  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
975  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
976  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
977  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
978  * information should then contain::
979  *
980  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
981  *
982  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
983  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
984  */
985 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
986 	s8 idx;
987 	u16 count:5,
988 	    flags:11;
989 } __packed;
990 
991 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
992 
993 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
994 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
995 {
996 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
997 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
998 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
999 }
1000 
1001 static inline u8
1002 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1003 {
1004 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1005 }
1006 
1007 static inline u8
1008 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1009 {
1010 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1011 }
1012 
1013 /**
1014  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1015  *
1016  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1017  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1018  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1019  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1020  *
1021  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1022  * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
1023  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1024  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1025  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1026  * @control: union part for control data
1027  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1028  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1029  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1030  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1031  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1032  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1033  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1034  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1035  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1036  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1037  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1038  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1039  * @pad: padding
1040  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1041  * @status: union part for status data
1042  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1043  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1044  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1045  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1046  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1047  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1048  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1049  * @status.is_valid_ack_signal: ACK signal is valid
1050  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1051  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1052  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1053  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1054  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1055  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1056  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1057  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1058  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1059  */
1060 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1061 	/* common information */
1062 	u32 flags;
1063 	u32 band:3,
1064 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1065 	    hw_queue:4,
1066 	    tx_time_est:10;
1067 	/* 2 free bits */
1068 
1069 	union {
1070 		struct {
1071 			union {
1072 				/* rate control */
1073 				struct {
1074 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1075 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1076 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1077 					u8 use_rts:1;
1078 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1079 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1080 					u8 skip_table:1;
1081 					/* 2 bytes free */
1082 				};
1083 				/* only needed before rate control */
1084 				unsigned long jiffies;
1085 			};
1086 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1087 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1088 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1089 			u32 flags;
1090 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1091 		} control;
1092 		struct {
1093 			u64 cookie;
1094 		} ack;
1095 		struct {
1096 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1097 			s32 ack_signal;
1098 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1099 			u8 ampdu_len;
1100 			u8 antenna;
1101 			u16 tx_time;
1102 			bool is_valid_ack_signal;
1103 			void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
1104 		} status;
1105 		struct {
1106 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1107 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1108 			u8 pad[4];
1109 
1110 			void *rate_driver_data[
1111 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1112 		};
1113 		void *driver_data[
1114 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1115 	};
1116 };
1117 
1118 static inline u16
1119 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1120 {
1121 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1122 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1123 	 */
1124 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1125 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1126 }
1127 
1128 static inline u16
1129 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1130 {
1131 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1132 }
1133 
1134 /**
1135  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1136  *
1137  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1138  * @info: Basic tx status information
1139  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1140  * @rate: The TX rate that was used when sending the packet
1141  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1142  */
1143 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1144 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1145 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1146 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1147 	struct rate_info *rate;
1148 	struct list_head *free_list;
1149 };
1150 
1151 /**
1152  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1153  *
1154  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1155  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1156  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1157  *
1158  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1159  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1160  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1161  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1162  */
1163 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1164 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1165 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1166 	const u8 *common_ies;
1167 	size_t common_ie_len;
1168 };
1169 
1170 
1171 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1172 {
1173 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1174 }
1175 
1176 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1177 {
1178 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1179 }
1180 
1181 /**
1182  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1183  *
1184  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1185  *
1186  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1187  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1188  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1189  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1190  *
1191  * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1192  *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1193  *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1194  */
1195 static inline void
1196 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1197 {
1198 	int i;
1199 
1200 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1201 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1202 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1203 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1204 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1205 	/* clear the rate counts */
1206 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1207 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1208 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1209 }
1210 
1211 
1212 /**
1213  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1214  *
1215  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1216  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1217  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1218  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1219  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1220  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1221  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1222  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1223  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1224  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1225  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1226  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1227  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1228  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1229  *	de-duplication by itself.
1230  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1231  *	the frame.
1232  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1233  *	the frame.
1234  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1235  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1236  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1237  *	merging.
1238  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1239  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1240  *	(including FCS) was received.
1241  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1242  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1243  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1244  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1245  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1246  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1247  *	each A-MPDU
1248  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1249  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1250  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1251  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1252  *	on this subframe
1253  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1254  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1255  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1256  *	done by the hardware
1257  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1258  *	processing it in any regular way.
1259  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1260  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1261  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1262  *	monitor interfaces.
1263  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1264  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1265  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1266  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1267  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1268  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1269  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1270  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1271  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1272  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1273  *	interleaved with other frames.
1274  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1275  *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1276  *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1277  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1278  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1279  *	the first subframe.
1280  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1281  *	be done in the hardware.
1282  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1283  *	frame
1284  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1285  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1286  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1287  *
1288  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1289  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1290  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1291  *	 - DATA5_GI
1292  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1293  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1294  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1295  *
1296  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1297  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1298  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1299  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1300  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1301  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1302  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1303  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1304  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1305  *	hardware or driver)
1306  */
1307 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1308 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1309 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1310 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1311 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1312 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1313 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1314 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1315 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1316 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1317 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1318 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1319 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1320 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1321 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1322 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1323 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1324 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1325 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1326 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1327 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1328 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1329 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1330 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1331 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1332 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1333 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1334 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1335 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1336 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1337 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1338 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1339 };
1340 
1341 /**
1342  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1343  *
1344  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1345  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1346  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1347  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1348  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1349  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1350  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1351  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1352  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1353  */
1354 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1355 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1356 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1357 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1358 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1359 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1360 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1361 };
1362 
1363 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1364 
1365 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1366 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1367 	RX_ENC_HT,
1368 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1369 	RX_ENC_HE,
1370 };
1371 
1372 /**
1373  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1374  *
1375  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1376  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1377  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1378  *
1379  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1380  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1381  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1382  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1383  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1384  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1385  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1386  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1387  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1388  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1389  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1390  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1391  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1392  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1393  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1394  *	values were filled.
1395  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1396  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1397  * @antenna: antenna used
1398  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1399  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1400  * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1401  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1402  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1403  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1404  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1405  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1406  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1407  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1408  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1409  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1410  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1411  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1412  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1413  */
1414 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1415 	u64 mactime;
1416 	u64 boottime_ns;
1417 	u32 device_timestamp;
1418 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1419 	u32 flag;
1420 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1421 	u8 enc_flags;
1422 	u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1423 	u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
1424 	u8 rate_idx;
1425 	u8 nss;
1426 	u8 rx_flags;
1427 	u8 band;
1428 	u8 antenna;
1429 	s8 signal;
1430 	u8 chains;
1431 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1432 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1433 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1434 };
1435 
1436 static inline u32
1437 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1438 {
1439 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1440 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1441 }
1442 
1443 /**
1444  * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1445  * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1446  *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1447  *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1448  * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1449  *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1450  *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1451  *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1452  * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1453  * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1454  * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1455  *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1456  *	@data field.
1457  * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1458  *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1459  *	length
1460  * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1461  *
1462  * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1463  * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1464  * data.
1465  */
1466 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1467 	u32 present;
1468 	u8 align;
1469 	u8 oui[3];
1470 	u8 subns;
1471 	u8 pad;
1472 	u16 len;
1473 	u8 data[];
1474 } __packed;
1475 
1476 /**
1477  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1478  *
1479  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1480  *
1481  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1482  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1483  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1484  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1485  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1486  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1487  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1488  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1489  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1490  *	for more.
1491  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1492  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1493  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1494  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1495  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1496  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1497  *	operating channel.
1498  */
1499 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1500 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1501 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1502 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1503 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1504 };
1505 
1506 
1507 /**
1508  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1509  *
1510  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1511  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1512  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1513  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1514  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1515  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1516  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1517  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1518  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1519  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1520  */
1521 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1522 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1523 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1524 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1525 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1526 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1527 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1528 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1529 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1530 };
1531 
1532 /**
1533  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1534  *
1535  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1536  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1537  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1538  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1539  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1540  */
1541 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1542 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1543 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1544 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1545 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1546 
1547 	/* keep last */
1548 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1549 };
1550 
1551 /**
1552  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1553  *
1554  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1555  *
1556  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1557  *
1558  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1559  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1560  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1561  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1562  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1563  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1564  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1565  *
1566  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1567  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1568  *
1569  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1570  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1571  *
1572  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1573  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1574  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1575  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1576  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1577  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1578  *
1579  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1580  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1581  *	configured for an HT channel.
1582  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1583  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1584  */
1585 struct ieee80211_conf {
1586 	u32 flags;
1587 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1588 
1589 	u16 listen_interval;
1590 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1591 
1592 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1593 
1594 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1595 	bool radar_enabled;
1596 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1597 };
1598 
1599 /**
1600  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1601  *
1602  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1603  * operation.
1604  *
1605  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1606  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1607  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1608  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1609  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1610  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1611  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1612  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1613  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1614  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1615  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1616   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1617   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1618  */
1619 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1620 	u64 timestamp;
1621 	u32 device_timestamp;
1622 	bool block_tx;
1623 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1624 	u8 count;
1625 	u32 delay;
1626 };
1627 
1628 /**
1629  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1630  *
1631  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1632  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1633  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1634  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1635  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1636  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1637  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1638  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1639  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1640  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1641  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1642  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1643  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1644  */
1645 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1646 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1647 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1648 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1649 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1650 };
1651 
1652 
1653 /**
1654  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1655  *
1656  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1657  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1658  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1659  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1660  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1661  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1662  *	mac80211.
1663  */
1664 
1665 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1666 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1667 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1668 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1669 };
1670 
1671 /**
1672  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1673  *
1674  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1675  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1676  *
1677  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1678  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1679  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1680  * @addr: address of this interface
1681  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1682  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1683  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1684  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1685  *	for read access.
1686  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1687  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1688  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1689  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1690  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1691  * @offloaad_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1692  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1693  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1694  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1695  *	restrictions.
1696  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1697  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1698  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1699  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1700  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1701  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1702  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1703  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1704  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1705  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1706  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1707  *	interface.
1708  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1709  *	for this interface.
1710  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1711  *	sizeof(void \*).
1712  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1713  * @txqs_stopped: per AC flag to indicate that intermediate TXQs are stopped,
1714  *	protected by fq->lock.
1715  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1716  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1717  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
1718  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1719  *	for read access.
1720  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
1721  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1722  */
1723 struct ieee80211_vif {
1724 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1725 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1726 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1727 	bool p2p;
1728 	bool csa_active;
1729 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
1730 
1731 	u8 cab_queue;
1732 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1733 
1734 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1735 
1736 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1737 
1738 	u32 driver_flags;
1739 	u32 offload_flags;
1740 
1741 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1742 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1743 #endif
1744 
1745 	bool probe_req_reg;
1746 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1747 
1748 	bool txqs_stopped[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1749 
1750 	bool color_change_active;
1751 	u8 color_change_color;
1752 
1753 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1754 
1755 	/* must be last */
1756 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1757 };
1758 
1759 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1760 {
1761 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1762 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1763 #endif
1764 	return false;
1765 }
1766 
1767 /**
1768  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1769  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1770  *
1771  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1772  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1773  *
1774  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1775  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1776  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1777  */
1778 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1779 
1780 /**
1781  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1782  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1783  *
1784  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1785  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1786  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1787  */
1788 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1789 
1790 /**
1791  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1792  *
1793  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1794  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1795  *
1796  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1797  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1798  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1799  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1800  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1801  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1802  *	generation in software.
1803  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1804  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1805  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1806  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1807  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1808  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1809  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1810  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1811  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1812  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1813  *	MIC.
1814  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1815  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1816  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1817  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1818  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1819  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1820  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1821  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1822  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1823  *	only for management frames (MFP).
1824  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1825  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1826  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1827  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1828  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1829  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1830  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1831  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1832  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1833  *	generation only
1834  */
1835 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1836 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1837 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1838 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1839 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1840 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1841 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1842 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1843 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1844 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1845 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
1846 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
1847 };
1848 
1849 /**
1850  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1851  *
1852  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1853  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1854  *
1855  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1856  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1857  *	encrypted in hardware.
1858  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1859  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1860  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1861  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1862  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1863  * @keylen: key material length
1864  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1865  * 	data block:
1866  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1867  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1868  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1869  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1870  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1871  */
1872 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1873 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
1874 	u32 cipher;
1875 	u8 icv_len;
1876 	u8 iv_len;
1877 	u8 hw_key_idx;
1878 	s8 keyidx;
1879 	u16 flags;
1880 	u8 keylen;
1881 	u8 key[];
1882 };
1883 
1884 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
1885 
1886 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1887 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1888 
1889 /**
1890  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1891  *
1892  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1893  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1894  *	reverse order than in packet)
1895  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1896  *	reverse order than in packet)
1897  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1898  *	reverse order than in packet)
1899  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1900  *	reverse order than in packet)
1901  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1902  */
1903 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1904 	union {
1905 		struct {
1906 			u32 iv32;
1907 			u16 iv16;
1908 		} tkip;
1909 		struct {
1910 			u8 pn[6];
1911 		} ccmp;
1912 		struct {
1913 			u8 pn[6];
1914 		} aes_cmac;
1915 		struct {
1916 			u8 pn[6];
1917 		} aes_gmac;
1918 		struct {
1919 			u8 pn[6];
1920 		} gcmp;
1921 		struct {
1922 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1923 			u8 seq_len;
1924 		} hw;
1925 	};
1926 };
1927 
1928 /**
1929  * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1930  *
1931  * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1932  * the secure packet crypto handling.
1933  *
1934  * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1935  * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1936  * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1937  * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1938  * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1939  * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1940  * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1941  * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1942  *     key_idx value calculation:
1943  *      (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1944  * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1945  */
1946 struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1947 	u32 cipher;
1948 	u16 iftype;
1949 	u8 hdr_len;
1950 	u8 pn_len;
1951 	u8 pn_off;
1952 	u8 key_idx_off;
1953 	u8 key_idx_mask;
1954 	u8 key_idx_shift;
1955 	u8 mic_len;
1956 };
1957 
1958 /**
1959  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1960  *
1961  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1962  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1963  *
1964  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1965  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1966  */
1967 enum set_key_cmd {
1968 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1969 };
1970 
1971 /**
1972  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1973  *
1974  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1975  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1976  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1977  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1978  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1979  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1980  */
1981 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1982 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1983 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1984 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1985 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1986 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1987 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1988 };
1989 
1990 /**
1991  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1992  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1993  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1994  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1995  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1996  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
1997  *
1998  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1999  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2000  */
2001 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2002 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2003 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2004 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2005 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2006 };
2007 
2008 /**
2009  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2010  *
2011  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2012  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2013  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2014  */
2015 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2016 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2017 	struct {
2018 		s8 idx;
2019 		u8 count;
2020 		u8 count_cts;
2021 		u8 count_rts;
2022 		u16 flags;
2023 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2024 };
2025 
2026 /**
2027  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2028  *
2029  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2030  *
2031  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2032  *	to the STA.
2033  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2034  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2035  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2036  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2037  *	per peer TPC.
2038  */
2039 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2040 	s16 power;
2041 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2042 };
2043 
2044 /**
2045  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2046  *
2047  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2048  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2049  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2050  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2051  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2052  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2053  *
2054  * @addr: MAC address
2055  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2056  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
2057  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2058  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2059  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2060  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2061  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2062  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2063  *	Can be modified by driver.
2064  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2065  *	otherwise always false)
2066  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2067  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2068  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2069  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2070  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2071  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2072  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2073  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2074  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2075  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2076  *	the station moves to associated state.
2077  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2078  * @rates: rate control selection table
2079  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2080  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2081  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2082  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2083  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2084  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2085  *	unlimited.
2086  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2087  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2088  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2089  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2090  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction); note that
2091  *	the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) is used for non-data frames
2092  */
2093 struct ieee80211_sta {
2094 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2095 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2096 	u16 aid;
2097 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2098 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2099 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2100 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2101 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2102 	bool wme;
2103 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2104 	u8 max_sp;
2105 	u8 rx_nss;
2106 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2107 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2108 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2109 	bool tdls;
2110 	bool tdls_initiator;
2111 	bool mfp;
2112 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2113 
2114 	/**
2115 	 * @max_amsdu_len:
2116 	 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2117 	 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2118 	 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2119 	 *
2120 	 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2121 	 *   A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2122 	 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2123 	 *   size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2124 	 *
2125 	 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2126 	 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2127 	 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2128 	 */
2129 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2130 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2131 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2132 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2133 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2134 
2135 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2136 
2137 	/* must be last */
2138 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2139 };
2140 
2141 /**
2142  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2143  *
2144  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2145  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2146  *
2147  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2148  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2149  */
2150 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2151 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2152 };
2153 
2154 /**
2155  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2156  *
2157  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2158  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2159  */
2160 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2161 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2162 };
2163 
2164 /**
2165  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2166  *
2167  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2168  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2169  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2170  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2171  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2172  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2173  *
2174  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2175  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2176  */
2177 struct ieee80211_txq {
2178 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2179 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2180 	u8 tid;
2181 	u8 ac;
2182 
2183 	/* must be last */
2184 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2185 };
2186 
2187 /**
2188  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2189  *
2190  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2191  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2192  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2193  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2194  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2195  *
2196  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2197  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2198  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2199  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2200  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2201  *	algorithm.
2202  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2203  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2204  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2205  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2206  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2207  *	CCK frames.
2208  *
2209  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2210  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2211  *	the FCS at the end.
2212  *
2213  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2214  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2215  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2216  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2217  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2218  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2219  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2220  *
2221  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2222  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2223  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2224  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2225  *
2226  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2227  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2228  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2229  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2230  *
2231  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2232  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2233  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2234  *
2235  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2236  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2237  *
2238  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2239  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2240  *
2241  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2242  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2243  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2244  *
2245  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2246  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2247  *
2248  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2249  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2250  *
2251  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2252  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2253  *	the stack.
2254  *
2255  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2256  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2257  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2258  *
2259  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2260  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2261  *	dtim_period).
2262  *
2263  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2264  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2265  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2266  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2267  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2268  *	only in that case.
2269  *
2270  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2271  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2272  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2273  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2274  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2275  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2276  *
2277  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2278  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2279  *	software.
2280  *
2281  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2282  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2283  *	active interfaces.
2284  *
2285  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2286  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2287  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2288  *
2289  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2290  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2291  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2292  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2293  *	supported cipher suites.
2294  *
2295  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2296  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2297  *	for frames.
2298  *
2299  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2300  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2301  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2302  *	control for more details.
2303  *
2304  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2305  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2306  *
2307  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2308  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2309  *	is supported.
2310  *
2311  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2312  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2313  *
2314  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2315  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2316  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2317  *
2318  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2319  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2320  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2321  *	CSA frame.
2322  *
2323  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2324  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2325  *
2326  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2327  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2328  *
2329  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2330  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2331  *
2332  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2333  *	within A-MPDU.
2334  *
2335  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2336  *	for sent beacons.
2337  *
2338  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2339  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2340  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2341  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2342  *
2343  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2344  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2345  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2346  *	timeout.
2347  *
2348  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2349  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2350  *
2351  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2352  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2353  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2354  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2355  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2356  *
2357  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2358  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2359  *
2360  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2361  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2362  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2363  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2364  *
2365  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2366  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2367  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2368  *
2369  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2370  *	TDLS links.
2371  *
2372  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2373  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2374  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2375  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2376  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2377  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2378  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2379  *
2380  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2381  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2382  *
2383  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2384  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2385  *
2386  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2387  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2388  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2389  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2390  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2391  *
2392  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2393  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2394  *	TXQs to start with.
2395  *
2396  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2397  *	length in tx status information
2398  *
2399  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2400  *
2401  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2402  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2403  *
2404  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2405  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2406  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2407  *
2408  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2409  *	offload
2410  *
2411  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2412  *	offload
2413  *
2414  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2415  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2416  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2417  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2418  *	the stack.
2419  *
2420  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2421  */
2422 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2423 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2424 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2425 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2426 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2427 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2428 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2429 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2430 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2431 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2432 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2433 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2434 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2435 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2436 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2437 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2438 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2439 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2440 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2441 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2442 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2443 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2444 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2445 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2446 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2447 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2448 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2449 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2450 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2451 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2452 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2453 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2454 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2455 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2456 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2457 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2458 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2459 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2460 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2461 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2462 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2463 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2464 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2465 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2466 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2467 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2468 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2469 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2470 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2471 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2472 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2473 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2474 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2475 
2476 	/* keep last, obviously */
2477 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2478 };
2479 
2480 /**
2481  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2482  *
2483  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2484  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2485  *
2486  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2487  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2488  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2489  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2490  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2491  *
2492  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2493  *
2494  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2495  *	along with this structure.
2496  *
2497  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2498  *
2499  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2500  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2501  *
2502  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2503  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2504  *
2505  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2506  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2507  *
2508  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2509  *	that HW supports
2510  *
2511  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2512  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2513  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2514  *
2515  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2516  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2517  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2518  *
2519  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2520  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2521  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2522  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2523  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2524  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2525  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2526  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2527  *
2528  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2529  *	can handle.
2530  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2531  *	the hw can report back.
2532  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2533  *
2534  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2535  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2536  *	aggregation.
2537  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2538  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2539  *	it shouldn't be set.
2540  *
2541  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2542  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2543  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2544  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2545  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2546  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2547  *
2548  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2549  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2550  *
2551  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2552  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2553  *
2554  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2555  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2556  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2557  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2558  *
2559  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2560  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2561  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2562  *
2563  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2564  *
2565  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2566  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2567  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2568  *	device_timestamp.
2569  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2570  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2571  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2572  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2573  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2574  *
2575  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2576  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2577  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2578  *
2579  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2580  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2581  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2582  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2583  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2584  *	neither enabled.
2585  *
2586  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2587  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2588  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2589  *
2590  * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2591  * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2592  *	supported by HW.
2593  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2594  *	device.
2595  *
2596  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2597  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2598  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2599  *
2600  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2601  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2602  *
2603  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2604  */
2605 struct ieee80211_hw {
2606 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2607 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2608 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2609 	void *priv;
2610 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2611 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2612 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2613 	int vif_data_size;
2614 	int sta_data_size;
2615 	int chanctx_data_size;
2616 	int txq_data_size;
2617 	u16 queues;
2618 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2619 	s8 max_signal;
2620 	u8 max_rates;
2621 	u8 max_report_rates;
2622 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2623 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2624 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2625 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2626 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2627 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2628 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2629 	struct {
2630 		int units_pos;
2631 		s16 accuracy;
2632 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2633 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2634 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2635 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2636 	u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2637 	const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2638 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2639 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2640 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2641 	u32 max_mtu;
2642 };
2643 
2644 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2645 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2646 {
2647 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2648 }
2649 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2650 
2651 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2652 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2653 {
2654 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2655 }
2656 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2657 
2658 /**
2659  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2660  *
2661  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2662  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2663  */
2664 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2665 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2666 
2667 	/* Keep last */
2668 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2669 };
2670 
2671 /**
2672  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2673  *
2674  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2675  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2676  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2677  * @status: channel-switch response status
2678  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2679  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2680  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2681  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2682  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2683  */
2684 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2685 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2686 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2687 	u8 action_code;
2688 	u32 status;
2689 	u32 timestamp;
2690 	u16 switch_time;
2691 	u16 switch_timeout;
2692 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2693 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2694 };
2695 
2696 /**
2697  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2698  *
2699  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2700  *
2701  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2702  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2703  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2704  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2705  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2706  *
2707  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2708  */
2709 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2710 
2711 /**
2712  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2713  *
2714  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2715  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2716  */
2717 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2718 {
2719 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2720 }
2721 
2722 /**
2723  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2724  *
2725  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2726  * @addr: the address to set
2727  */
2728 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2729 {
2730 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2731 }
2732 
2733 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2734 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2735 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2736 {
2737 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2738 		return NULL;
2739 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2740 }
2741 
2742 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2743 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2744 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2745 {
2746 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2747 		return NULL;
2748 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2749 }
2750 
2751 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2752 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2753 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2754 {
2755 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2756 		return NULL;
2757 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2758 }
2759 
2760 /**
2761  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2762  * @hw: the hardware
2763  * @skb: the skb
2764  *
2765  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2766  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2767  */
2768 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2769 
2770 /**
2771  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2772  *
2773  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2774  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2775  *
2776  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2777  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2778  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2779  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2780  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2781  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2782  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2783  *
2784  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2785  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2786  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2787  *
2788  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2789  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2790  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2791  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2792  *
2793  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2794  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2795  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2796  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2797  *
2798  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2799  *
2800  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2801  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2802  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2803  * based on the receive flags.
2804  *
2805  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2806  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2807  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2808  * keys.
2809  *
2810  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2811  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2812  * handler.
2813  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2814  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2815  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2816  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2817  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2818  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2819  *
2820  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2821  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2822  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2823  *
2824  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
2825  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
2826  * requirements:
2827  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
2828       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
2829    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
2830       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
2831    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
2832       encrypted with the new key when also needing
2833       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
2834    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
2835    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
2836  */
2837 
2838 /**
2839  * DOC: Powersave support
2840  *
2841  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2842  *
2843  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2844  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2845  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2846  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2847  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2848  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2849  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2850  * it finds traffic directed to it.
2851  *
2852  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2853  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2854  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2855  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2856  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2857  *
2858  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2859  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2860  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2861  *
2862  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2863  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2864  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2865  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2866  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2867  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2868  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2869  *
2870  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2871  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2872  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2873  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2874  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2875  * periods.
2876  *
2877  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2878  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2879  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2880  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2881  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2882  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2883  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2884  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2885  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2886  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2887  *
2888  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2889  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2890  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2891  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2892  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2893  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2894  *
2895  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2896  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2897  */
2898 
2899 /**
2900  * DOC: Beacon filter support
2901  *
2902  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2903  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2904  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2905  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2906  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2907  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2908  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2909  *
2910  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2911  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2912  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2913  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2914  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2915  *
2916  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2917  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2918  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2919  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2920  *
2921  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2922  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2923  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2924  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2925  *
2926  *  - a list of information element IDs
2927  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2928  *
2929  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2930  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2931  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2932  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2933  * vendor information elements.
2934  *
2935  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2936  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2937  *
2938  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2939  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2940  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2941  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2942  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2943  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2944  *
2945  *
2946  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2947  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2948  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2949  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2950  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2951  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2952  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2953  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2954  *
2955  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2956  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2957  * signal strength threshold checking.
2958  */
2959 
2960 /**
2961  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2962  *
2963  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2964  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2965  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2966  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2967  *
2968  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2969  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2970  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2971  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2972  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2973  * hardware flags.
2974  *
2975  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2976  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2977  * turned off otherwise.
2978  *
2979  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2980  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2981  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2982  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2983  */
2984 
2985 /**
2986  * DOC: Frame filtering
2987  *
2988  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2989  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2990  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2991  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2992  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2993  *
2994  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2995  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2996  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2997  *
2998  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2999  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3000  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3001  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3002  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3003  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3004  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3005  *
3006  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3007  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3008  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3009  * or dropped.
3010  *
3011  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3012  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3013  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3014  * the flag, but not clear it.
3015  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3016  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3017  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3018  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3019  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3020  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3021  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3022  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3023  */
3024 
3025 /**
3026  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3027  *
3028  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3029  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3030  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3031  *
3032  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3033  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3034  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3035  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3036  * the driver code.
3037  *
3038  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3039  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3040  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3041  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3042  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3043  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3044  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3045  *
3046  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3047  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3048  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3049  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3050  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3051  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3052  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3053  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3054  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3055  * @sta_notify callback.
3056  *
3057  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3058  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3059  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3060  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3061  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3062  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3063  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3064  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3065  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3066  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3067  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3068  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3069  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3070  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3071  *
3072  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3073  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3074  *
3075  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3076  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3077  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3078  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3079  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3080  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3081  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3082  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3083  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3084  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3085  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3086  *
3087  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3088  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3089  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3090  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3091  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3092  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3093  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3094  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3095  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3096  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3097  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3098  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3099  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3100  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3101  *
3102  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3103  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3104  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3105  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3106  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3107  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3108  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3109  *
3110  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3111  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3112  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3113  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3114  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3115  *
3116  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3117  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3118  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3119  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3120  */
3121 
3122 /**
3123  * DOC: HW queue control
3124  *
3125  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3126  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3127  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3128  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3129  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3130  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3131  *
3132  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3133  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3134  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3135  *
3136  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3137  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3138  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3139  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3140  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3141  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3142  * the hardware queue.
3143  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3144  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3145  *
3146  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3147  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3148  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3149  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3150  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3151  *
3152  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3153  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3154  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3155  * off-channel queue:         9
3156  *
3157  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3158  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3159  *
3160  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3161  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3162  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3163  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3164  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3165  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3166  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3167  *
3168  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3169  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3170  *
3171  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3172  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3173  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3174  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3175  */
3176 
3177 /**
3178  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3179  *
3180  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3181  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3182  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3183  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3184  *
3185  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3186  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3187  *	multicast address.
3188  *
3189  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3190  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3191  *
3192  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3193  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3194  *
3195  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3196  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3197  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3198  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3199  *	honour this flag if possible.
3200  *
3201  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3202  *	station
3203  *
3204  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3205  *
3206  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3207  *
3208  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3209  *
3210  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3211  */
3212 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3213 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3214 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3215 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3216 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3217 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3218 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3219 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3220 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3221 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3222 };
3223 
3224 /**
3225  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3226  *
3227  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3228  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3229  *
3230  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3231  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3232  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3233  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3234  *
3235  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3236  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3237  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3238  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3239  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3240  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3241  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3242  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3243  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3244  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3245  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3246  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3247  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3248  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3249  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3250  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3251  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3252  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3253  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3254  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3255  */
3256 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3257 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3258 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3259 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3260 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3261 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3262 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3263 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3264 };
3265 
3266 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3267 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3268 
3269 /**
3270  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3271  *
3272  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3273  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3274  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3275  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3276  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3277  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3278  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3279  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3280  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3281  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3282  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3283  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3284  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3285  */
3286 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3287 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3288 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3289 	u16 tid;
3290 	u16 ssn;
3291 	u16 buf_size;
3292 	bool amsdu;
3293 	u16 timeout;
3294 };
3295 
3296 /**
3297  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3298  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3299  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3300  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3301  */
3302 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3303 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3304 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3305 };
3306 
3307 /**
3308  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3309  *
3310  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3311  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3312  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3313  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3314  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3315  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3316  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3317  *	the peer.
3318  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3319  *	by the peer
3320  */
3321 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3322 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3323 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3324 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3325 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3326 };
3327 
3328 /**
3329  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3330  *
3331  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3332  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3333  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3334  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3335  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3336  *
3337  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3338  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3339  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3340  */
3341 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3342 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3343 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3344 };
3345 
3346 /**
3347  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3348  *
3349  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3350  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3351  *
3352  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3353  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3354  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3355  *	of wowlan configuration)
3356  */
3357 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3358 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3359 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3360 };
3361 
3362 /**
3363  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3364  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3365  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3366  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3367  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3368  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3369  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3370  */
3371 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3372 	u16 duration;
3373 	u16 subtype;
3374 	u8 success:1;
3375 };
3376 
3377 /**
3378  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3379  *
3380  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3381  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3382  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3383  *
3384  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3385  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3386  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3387  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3388  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3389  *	Must be atomic.
3390  *
3391  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3392  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3393  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3394  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3395  *	or zero.
3396  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3397  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3398  *	is added.
3399  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3400  *
3401  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3402  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3403  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3404  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3405  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3406  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3407  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3408  *
3409  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3410  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3411  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3412  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3413  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3414  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3415  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3416  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3417  *	must return 1 from this function.
3418  *
3419  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3420  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3421  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3422  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3423  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3424  *
3425  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3426  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3427  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3428  *	in suspend().
3429  *
3430  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3431  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3432  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3433  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3434  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3435  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3436  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3437  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3438  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3439  *
3440  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3441  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3442  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3443  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3444  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3445  *
3446  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3447  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3448  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3449  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3450  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3451  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3452  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3453  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3454  *
3455  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3456  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3457  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3458  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3459  *
3460  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3461  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3462  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3463  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3464  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3465  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3466  *	can sleep.
3467  *
3468  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3469  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3470  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3471  *
3472  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3473  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3474  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3475  *
3476  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3477  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3478  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3479  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3480  *	which flags are changed.
3481  *	This callback can sleep.
3482  *
3483  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3484  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3485  *
3486  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3487  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3488  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3489  *	is enabled.
3490  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3491  *	The callback can sleep.
3492  *
3493  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3494  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3495  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3496  *	The callback must be atomic.
3497  *
3498  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3499  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3500  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3501  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3502  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3503  *
3504  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3505  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3506  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3507  *
3508  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3509  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3510  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3511  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3512  *	that power save is disabled.
3513  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3514  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3515  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3516  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3517  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3518  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3519  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3520  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3521  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3522  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3523  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3524  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3525  *	The callback can sleep.
3526  *
3527  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3528  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3529  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3530  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3531  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3532  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3533  *	The callback can sleep.
3534  *
3535  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3536  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3537  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3538  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3539  *
3540  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3541  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3542  *
3543  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3544  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3545  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3546  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3547  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3548  *
3549  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3550  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3551  *	this notification.
3552  *	The callback can sleep.
3553  *
3554  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3555  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3556  *	The callback can sleep.
3557  *
3558  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3559  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3560  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3561  *	The callback must be atomic.
3562  *
3563  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3564  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3565  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3566  *	should be set as well.
3567  *	The callback can sleep.
3568  *
3569  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3570  *	The callback can sleep.
3571  *
3572  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3573  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3574  *
3575  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3576  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3577  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3578  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3579  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3580  *	This callback can sleep.
3581  *
3582  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3583  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3584  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3585  *	callback can sleep.
3586  *
3587  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3588  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3589  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3590  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3591  *
3592  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3593  *	power for the station.
3594  *	This callback can sleep.
3595  *
3596  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3597  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3598  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3599  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3600  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3601  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3602  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3603  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3604  *	The callback can sleep.
3605  *
3606  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3607  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3608  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3609  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3610  *	in @sta_state.
3611  *	The callback can sleep.
3612  *
3613  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3614  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3615  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3616  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3617  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3618  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3619  *	Must be atomic.
3620  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3621  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3622  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3623  *
3624  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3625  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3626  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3627  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3628  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3629  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3630  *	The callback can sleep.
3631  *
3632  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3633  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3634  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3635  *	The callback can sleep.
3636  *
3637  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3638  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3639  *	required function.
3640  *	The callback can sleep.
3641  *
3642  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3643  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3644  *	required function.
3645  *	The callback can sleep.
3646  *
3647  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3648  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3649  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3650  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3651  *	The callback can sleep.
3652  *
3653  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3654  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3655  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3656  *	TSF synchronization.
3657  *	The callback can sleep.
3658  *
3659  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3660  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3661  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3662  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3663  *	The callback can sleep.
3664  *
3665  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3666  *
3667  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3668  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3669  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3670  *	The callback can sleep.
3671  *
3672  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3673  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3674  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3675  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3676  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3677  *
3678  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3679  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3680  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3681  *
3682  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3683  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3684  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3685  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3686  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3687  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3688  *	The callback can sleep.
3689  *
3690  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3691  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3692  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3693  *	completion of the channel switch.
3694  *
3695  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3696  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3697  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3698  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3699  *
3700  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3701  *
3702  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3703  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3704  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3705  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3706  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3707  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3708  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3709  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3710  *	must be accepted in this case.
3711  *	This callback may sleep.
3712  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3713  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3714  *
3715  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3716  *
3717  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3718  *
3719  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3720  *	queues before entering power save.
3721  *
3722  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3723  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3724  *	The callback can sleep.
3725  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3726  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3727  *	The callback must be atomic.
3728  *
3729  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3730  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3731  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3732  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3733  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3734  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3735  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3736  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3737  *	more-data bit must always be set.
3738  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3739  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3740  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3741  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3742  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3743  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3744  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3745  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3746  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3747  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3748  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3749  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3750  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3751  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3752  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3753  *	This callback must be atomic.
3754  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3755  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3756  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3757  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3758  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3759  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3760  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3761  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3762  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3763  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3764  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3765  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3766  *	This callback must be atomic.
3767  *
3768  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3769  *
3770  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3771  *
3772  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3773  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3774  *
3775  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3776  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3777  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3778  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3779  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3780  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3781  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3782  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3783  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3784  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3785  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3786  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3787  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3788  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3789  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
3790  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
3791  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
3792  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3793  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
3794  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
3795  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
3796  *
3797  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3798  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3799  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3800  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3801  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3802  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3803  *	2 * (DTIM period).
3804  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
3805  *
3806  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3807  *	This callback may sleep.
3808  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3809  *	This callback may sleep.
3810  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3811  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3812  *	channel context with different settings
3813  *	This callback may sleep.
3814  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3815  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3816  *	This callback may sleep.
3817  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3818  *	unbound from vif.
3819  *	This callback may sleep.
3820  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3821  *	another, as specified in the list of
3822  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3823  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3824  *	This callback may sleep.
3825  *
3826  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3827  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3828  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3829  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3830  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3831  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3832  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3833  *
3834  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3835  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3836  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3837  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3838  *	This callback may sleep.
3839  *
3840  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3841  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3842  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3843  *
3844  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3845  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3846  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3847  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3848  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3849  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3850  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3851  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3852  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3853  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3854  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3855  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3856  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3857  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3858  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3859  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3860  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3861  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3862  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
3863  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3864  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
3865  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
3866  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
3867  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3868  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3869  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
3870  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3871  *
3872  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3873  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3874  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3875  *
3876  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3877  *	and hardware limits.
3878  *
3879  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3880  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3881  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3882  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3883  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3884  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3885  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3886  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3887  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3888  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3889  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3890  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3891  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3892  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
3893  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3894  *	the function call.
3895  *
3896  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3897  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3898  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3899  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3900  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3901  *
3902  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3903  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3904  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3905  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3906  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3907  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3908  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3909  *	changed parameters.
3910  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3911  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3912  *	this call.
3913  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3914  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3915  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
3916  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
3917  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
3918  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
3919  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
3920  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3921  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3922  *
3923  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
3924  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
3925  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
3926  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
3927  *	This callback may sleep.
3928  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
3929  *	This callback may sleep.
3930  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
3931  *	4-address mode
3932  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
3933  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
3934  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
3935  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
3936  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
3937  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
3938  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
3939  *	twt structure.
3940  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
3941  *	from the peer.
3942  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
3943  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
3944  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
3945  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
3946  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
3947  *	radar channel.
3948  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
3949  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
3950  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
3951  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
3952  */
3953 struct ieee80211_ops {
3954 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3955 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3956 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
3957 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3958 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3959 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
3960 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3961 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3962 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3963 #endif
3964 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3965 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3966 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3967 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3968 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3969 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3970 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3971 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3972 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3973 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3974 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3975 				 u32 changed);
3976 
3977 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3978 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3979 
3980 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3981 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3982 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3983 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
3984 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
3985 				 u64 multicast);
3986 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3987 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3988 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
3989 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
3990 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3991 		       bool set);
3992 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3993 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3994 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3995 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3996 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3997 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3998 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3999 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4000 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4001 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4002 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4003 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4004 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4005 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4006 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4007 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4008 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4009 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4010 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4011 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4012 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4013 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4014 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4015 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4016 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4017 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4018 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4019 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4020 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4021 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4022 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4023 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4024 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4025 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4026 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4027 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4028 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4029 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4030 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4031 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4032 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4033 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4034 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4035 				struct dentry *dir);
4036 #endif
4037 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4038 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4039 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4040 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4041 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4042 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4043 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4044 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4045 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4046 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4047 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4048 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4049 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4050 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4051 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4052 			      u32 changed);
4053 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4054 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4055 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4056 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4057 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4058 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4059 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4060 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4061 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
4062 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4063 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4064 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4065 			u64 tsf);
4066 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4067 			   s64 offset);
4068 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4069 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4070 
4071 	/**
4072 	 * @ampdu_action:
4073 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4074 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4075 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4076 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4077 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4078 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4079 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4080 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4081 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4082 	 *
4083 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4084 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4085 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4086 	 *
4087 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4088 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4089 	 *
4090 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4091 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4092 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4093 	 *
4094 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4095 	 *
4096 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4097 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4098 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4099 	 *
4100 	 * The callback can sleep.
4101 	 */
4102 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4103 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4104 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4105 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4106 		struct survey_info *survey);
4107 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4108 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4109 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4110 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4111 			    void *data, int len);
4112 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4113 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4114 			     void *data, int len);
4115 #endif
4116 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4117 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4118 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4119 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4120 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4121 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4122 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4123 
4124 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4125 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4126 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4127 				 int duration,
4128 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4129 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4130 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4131 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4132 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4133 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4134 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4135 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4136 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4137 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4138 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4139 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4140 
4141 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4142 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4143 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4144 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4145 				      bool more_data);
4146 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4147 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4148 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4149 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4150 					bool more_data);
4151 
4152 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4153 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4154 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4155 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4156 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4157 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4158 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4159 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4160 
4161 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4162 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4163 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4164 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4165 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4166 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4167 
4168 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4169 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4170 
4171 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4172 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4173 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4174 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4175 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4176 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4177 			       u32 changed);
4178 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4179 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4180 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4181 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4182 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4183 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4184 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4185 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4186 				  int n_vifs,
4187 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4188 
4189 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4190 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4191 
4192 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4193 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4194 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4195 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4196 #endif
4197 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4198 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4199 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4200 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4201 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4202 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4203 
4204 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4205 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4206 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4207 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4208 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4209 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4210 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4211 
4212 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4213 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4214 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4215 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4216 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4217 			   int *dbm);
4218 
4219 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4220 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4221 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4222 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4223 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4224 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4225 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4226 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4227 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4228 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4229 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4230 
4231 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4232 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4233 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4234 
4235 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4236 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4237 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4238 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4239 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4240 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4241 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4242 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4243 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4244 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4245 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4246 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4247 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4248 			    u8 instance_id);
4249 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4250 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4251 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4252 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4253 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4254 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4255 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4256 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4257 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4258 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4259 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4260 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4261 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4262 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4263 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4264 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4265 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4266 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4267 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4268 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4269 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4270 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4271 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4272 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4273 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4274 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4275 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4276 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4277 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4278 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4279 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4280 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4281 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4282 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4283 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4284 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4285 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4286 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4287 };
4288 
4289 /**
4290  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4291  *
4292  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4293  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4294  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4295  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4296  * @priv_data_len.
4297  *
4298  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4299  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4300  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4301  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4302  *
4303  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4304  */
4305 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4306 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4307 					   const char *requested_name);
4308 
4309 /**
4310  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4311  *
4312  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4313  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4314  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4315  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4316  * @priv_data_len.
4317  *
4318  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4319  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4320  *
4321  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4322  */
4323 static inline
4324 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4325 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4326 {
4327 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4328 }
4329 
4330 /**
4331  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4332  *
4333  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4334  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4335  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4336  *
4337  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4338  *
4339  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4340  */
4341 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4342 
4343 /**
4344  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4345  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4346  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4347  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4348  */
4349 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4350 	int throughput;
4351 	int blink_time;
4352 };
4353 
4354 /**
4355  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4356  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4357  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4358  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4359  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4360  */
4361 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4362 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4363 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4364 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4365 };
4366 
4367 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4368 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4369 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4370 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4371 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4372 const char *
4373 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4374 				   unsigned int flags,
4375 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4376 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4377 #endif
4378 /**
4379  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4380  *
4381  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4382  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4383  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4384  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4385  *
4386  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4387  *
4388  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4389  */
4390 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4391 {
4392 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4393 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4394 #else
4395 	return NULL;
4396 #endif
4397 }
4398 
4399 /**
4400  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4401  *
4402  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4403  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4404  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4405  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4406  *
4407  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4408  *
4409  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4410  */
4411 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4412 {
4413 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4414 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4415 #else
4416 	return NULL;
4417 #endif
4418 }
4419 
4420 /**
4421  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4422  *
4423  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4424  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4425  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4426  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4427  *
4428  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4429  *
4430  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4431  */
4432 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4433 {
4434 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4435 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4436 #else
4437 	return NULL;
4438 #endif
4439 }
4440 
4441 /**
4442  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4443  *
4444  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4445  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4446  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4447  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4448  *
4449  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4450  *
4451  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4452  */
4453 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4454 {
4455 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4456 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4457 #else
4458 	return NULL;
4459 #endif
4460 }
4461 
4462 /**
4463  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4464  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4465  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4466  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4467  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4468  *
4469  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4470  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4471  *
4472  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4473  */
4474 static inline const char *
4475 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4476 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4477 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4478 {
4479 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4480 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4481 						  blink_table_len);
4482 #else
4483 	return NULL;
4484 #endif
4485 }
4486 
4487 /**
4488  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4489  *
4490  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4491  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4492  *
4493  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4494  */
4495 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4496 
4497 /**
4498  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4499  *
4500  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4501  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4502  * before calling this function.
4503  *
4504  * @hw: the hardware to free
4505  */
4506 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4507 
4508 /**
4509  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4510  *
4511  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4512  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4513  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4514  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4515  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4516  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4517  *
4518  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4519  */
4520 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4521 
4522 /**
4523  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4524  *
4525  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4526  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4527  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4528  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4529  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4530  *
4531  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4532  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4533  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4534  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4535  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4536  *
4537  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4538  *
4539  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4540  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4541  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4542  * @list: the destination list
4543  */
4544 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4545 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4546 
4547 /**
4548  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4549  *
4550  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4551  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4552  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4553  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4554  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4555  *
4556  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4557  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4558  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4559  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4560  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4561  *
4562  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4563  *
4564  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4565  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4566  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4567  * @napi: the NAPI context
4568  */
4569 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4570 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4571 
4572 /**
4573  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4574  *
4575  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4576  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4577  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4578  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4579  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4580  *
4581  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4582  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4583  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4584  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4585  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4586  *
4587  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4588  *
4589  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4590  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4591  */
4592 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4593 {
4594 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4595 }
4596 
4597 /**
4598  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4599  *
4600  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4601  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4602  *
4603  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4604  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4605  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4606  *
4607  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4608  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4609  */
4610 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4611 
4612 /**
4613  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4614  *
4615  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4616  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4617  *
4618  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4619  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4620  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4621  *
4622  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4623  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4624  */
4625 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4627 {
4628 	local_bh_disable();
4629 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4630 	local_bh_enable();
4631 }
4632 
4633 /**
4634  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4635  *
4636  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4637  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4638  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4639  *
4640  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4641  *
4642  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4643  * each other.
4644  *
4645  * @sta: currently connected sta
4646  * @start: start or stop PS
4647  *
4648  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4649  */
4650 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4651 
4652 /**
4653  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4654  *                                  (in process context)
4655  *
4656  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4657  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4658  * applies.
4659  *
4660  * @sta: currently connected sta
4661  * @start: start or stop PS
4662  *
4663  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4664  */
4665 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4666 						  bool start)
4667 {
4668 	int ret;
4669 
4670 	local_bh_disable();
4671 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4672 	local_bh_enable();
4673 
4674 	return ret;
4675 }
4676 
4677 /**
4678  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4679  * @sta: currently connected station
4680  *
4681  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4682  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4683  * connected station was received.
4684  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4685  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4686  * be serialized.
4687  */
4688 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4692  * @sta: currently connected station
4693  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4694  *
4695  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4696  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4697  * from a connected station was received.
4698  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4699  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4700  * serialized.
4701  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4702  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4703  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4704  * checks.
4705  */
4706 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4707 
4708 /*
4709  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4710  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4711  */
4712 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4713 
4714 /**
4715  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4716  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4717  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4718  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4719  *
4720  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4721  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4722  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4723  *
4724  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4725  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4726  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4727  * call! Beware of the locking!)
4728  *
4729  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4730  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4731  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4732  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4733  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4734  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4735  *
4736  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4737  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4738  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4739  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4740  * use this API.
4741  */
4742 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4743 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
4744 
4745 /**
4746  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4747  *
4748  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4749  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4750  * rate selection table for the station entry.
4751  *
4752  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4753  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4754  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4755  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4756  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4757  */
4758 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4760 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
4761 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4762 			    int max_rates);
4763 
4764 /**
4765  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4766  *
4767  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4768  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4769  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4770  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4771  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4772  * slow stations to starve).
4773  *
4774  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4775  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4776  */
4777 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4778 					   u32 thr);
4779 
4780 /**
4781  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
4782  *
4783  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
4784  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
4785  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
4786  *
4787  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4788  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
4789  * @info: tx status information
4790  */
4791 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4792 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4793 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
4794 
4795 /**
4796  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4797  *
4798  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4799  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4800  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4801  *
4802  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4803  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4804  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4805  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4806  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4807  *
4808  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4809  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4810  */
4811 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4812 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
4813 
4814 /**
4815  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4816  *
4817  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4818  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4819  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4820  *
4821  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4822  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4823  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4824  *
4825  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4826  * @status: tx status information
4827  */
4828 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4829 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4830 
4831 /**
4832  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4833  *
4834  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4835  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4836  * specific skbs.
4837  *
4838  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4839  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4840  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4841  *
4842  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4843  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4844  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
4845  * @info: tx status information
4846  */
4847 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4849 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4850 {
4851 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4852 		.sta = sta,
4853 		.info = info,
4854 	};
4855 
4856 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4857 }
4858 
4859 /**
4860  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4861  *
4862  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4863  *
4864  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4865  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4866  * for a single hardware.
4867  *
4868  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4869  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4870  */
4871 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4872 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
4873 {
4874 	local_bh_disable();
4875 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4876 	local_bh_enable();
4877 }
4878 
4879 /**
4880  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4881  *
4882  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4883  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4884  *
4885  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4886  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4887  *
4888  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4889  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4890  */
4891 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4892 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
4893 
4894 /**
4895  * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
4896  *
4897  * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
4898  * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
4899  * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
4900  * 802.11 frames.
4901  *
4902  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4903  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
4904  * calls in the same tx status family.
4905  *
4906  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4907  * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
4908  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4909  */
4910 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4911 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4912 			       struct sk_buff *skb);
4913 
4914 /**
4915  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4916  *
4917  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4918  * connected STA.
4919  *
4920  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4921  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4922  */
4923 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4924 
4925 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4926 
4927 /**
4928  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4929  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4930  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4931  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4932  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
4933  *	should be ignored.
4934  */
4935 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4936 	u16 tim_offset;
4937 	u16 tim_length;
4938 
4939 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
4940 };
4941 
4942 /**
4943  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4944  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4945  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4946  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4947  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
4948  *
4949  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4950  * obtain the beacon template.
4951  *
4952  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4953  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4954  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4955  * applicable, the CSA count.
4956  *
4957  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4958  *
4959  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4960  */
4961 struct sk_buff *
4962 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4963 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4964 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
4965 
4966 /**
4967  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4968  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4969  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4970  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4971  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4972  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4973  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
4974  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4975  *
4976  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4977  * obtain the beacon frame.
4978  *
4979  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4980  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4981  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4982  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
4983  *
4984  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4985  *
4986  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4987  */
4988 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4989 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4990 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
4991 
4992 /**
4993  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4994  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4995  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4996  *
4997  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4998  *
4999  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5000  */
5001 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5002 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
5003 {
5004 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
5005 }
5006 
5007 /**
5008  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5009  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5010  *
5011  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5012  * This function is called implicitly when
5013  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5014  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5015  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5016  *
5017  * Return: new countdown value
5018  */
5019 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5020 
5021 /**
5022  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5023  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5024  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5025  *
5026  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5027  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5028  *
5029  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5030  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5031  */
5032 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5033 
5034 /**
5035  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5036  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5037  *
5038  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5039  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5040  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5041  */
5042 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5043 
5044 /**
5045  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5046  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5047  *
5048  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5049  */
5050 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5051 
5052 /**
5053  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5054  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5055  *
5056  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5057  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5058  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5059  */
5060 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5061 
5062 /**
5063  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5064  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5065  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5066  *
5067  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5068  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5069  *
5070  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5071  *
5072  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5073  */
5074 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5075 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5076 
5077 /**
5078  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5079  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5080  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5081  *
5082  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5083  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5084  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5085  *
5086  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5087  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5088  *
5089  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5090  */
5091 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5092 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5093 
5094 /**
5095  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5096  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5097  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5098  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5099  *	if at all possible
5100  *
5101  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5102  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5103  * BSSID and address is used.
5104  *
5105  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5106  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5107  *
5108  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5109  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5110  *
5111  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5112  */
5113 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5114 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5115 				       bool qos_ok);
5116 
5117 /**
5118  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5119  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5120  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5121  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5122  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5123  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5124  *
5125  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5126  * hardware.
5127  *
5128  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5129  */
5130 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5131 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5132 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5133 				       size_t tailroom);
5134 
5135 /**
5136  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5137  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5138  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5139  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5140  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5141  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5142  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5143  *
5144  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5145  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5146  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5147  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5148  */
5149 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5150 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5151 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5152 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5153 
5154 /**
5155  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5156  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5157  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5158  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5159  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5160  *
5161  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5162  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5163  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5164  *
5165  * Return: The duration.
5166  */
5167 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5168 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5169 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5170 
5171 /**
5172  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5173  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5174  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5175  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5176  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5177  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5178  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5179  *
5180  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5181  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5182  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5183  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5184  */
5185 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5186 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5187 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5188 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5189 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5190 
5191 /**
5192  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5193  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5194  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5195  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5196  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5197  *
5198  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5199  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5200  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5201  *
5202  * Return: The duration.
5203  */
5204 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5205 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5206 				    size_t frame_len,
5207 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5208 
5209 /**
5210  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5211  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5212  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5213  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5214  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5215  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5216  *
5217  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5218  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5219  *
5220  * Return: The duration.
5221  */
5222 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5223 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5224 					enum nl80211_band band,
5225 					size_t frame_len,
5226 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5227 
5228 /**
5229  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5230  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5231  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5232  *
5233  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5234  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5235  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5236  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5237  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5238  *
5239  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5240  * frames are available.
5241  *
5242  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5243  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5244  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5245  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5246  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5247  * use common code for all beacons.
5248  */
5249 struct sk_buff *
5250 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5251 
5252 /**
5253  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5254  *
5255  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5256  *
5257  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5258  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5259  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5260  */
5261 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5262 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5263 
5264 /**
5265  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5266  *
5267  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5268  * from the given packet.
5269  *
5270  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5271  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5272  *	with this P1K
5273  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5274  */
5275 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5276 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5277 {
5278 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5279 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5280 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5281 
5282 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5283 }
5284 
5285 /**
5286  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5287  *
5288  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5289  * and transmitter address.
5290  *
5291  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5292  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5293  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5294  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5295  */
5296 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5297 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5298 
5299 /**
5300  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5301  *
5302  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5303  * in the packet.
5304  *
5305  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5306  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5307  *	encrypted with this key
5308  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5309  */
5310 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5311 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5312 
5313 /**
5314  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5315  *
5316  * @pos: start of crypto header
5317  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5318  * @pn: PN to add
5319  *
5320  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5321  * the packet payload)
5322  *
5323  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5324  * point to the crypto header)
5325  */
5326 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5327 
5328 /**
5329  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5330  *
5331  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5332  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5333  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5334  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5335  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5336  *
5337  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5338  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5339  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5340  *
5341  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5342  * can be done concurrently.
5343  */
5344 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5345 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5349  *
5350  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5351  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5352  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5353  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5354  * @seq: new sequence data
5355  *
5356  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5357  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5358  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5359  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5360  *
5361  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5362  * can be done concurrently.
5363  */
5364 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5365 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5366 
5367 /**
5368  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5369  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5370  *
5371  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5372  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5373  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5374  *
5375  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5376  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5377  */
5378 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5379 
5380 /**
5381  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5382  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5383  * @keyconf: new key data
5384  *
5385  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5386  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5387  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5388  *
5389  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5390  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5391  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5392  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5393  *
5394  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5395  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5396  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5397  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5398  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5399  * of the reconfiguration.
5400  *
5401  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5402  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5403  *
5404  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5405  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5406  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5407  * the key that's being replaced.
5408  */
5409 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5410 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5411 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5412 
5413 /**
5414  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5415  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5416  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5417  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5418  * @gfp: allocation flags
5419  */
5420 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5421 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5422 
5423 /**
5424  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5425  *
5426  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5427  * at the same time.
5428  *
5429  * @keyconf: the key in question
5430  */
5431 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5432 
5433 /**
5434  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5435  *
5436  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5437  * at the same time.
5438  *
5439  * @keyconf: the key in question
5440  */
5441 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5442 
5443 /**
5444  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5445  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5446  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5447  *
5448  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5449  */
5450 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5451 
5452 /**
5453  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5454  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5455  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5456  *
5457  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5458  */
5459 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5460 
5461 /**
5462  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5463  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5464  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5465  *
5466  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5467  *
5468  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5469  */
5470 
5471 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5472 
5473 /**
5474  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5475  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5476  *
5477  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5478  */
5479 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5480 
5481 /**
5482  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5483  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5484  *
5485  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5486  */
5487 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5488 
5489 /**
5490  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5491  *
5492  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5493  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5494  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5495  * any context, including hardirq context.
5496  *
5497  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5498  * @info: information about the completed scan
5499  */
5500 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5501 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5502 
5503 /**
5504  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5505  *
5506  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5507  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5508  *
5509  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5510  */
5511 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5512 
5513 /**
5514  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5515  *
5516  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5517  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5518  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5519  * while associating, for instance.
5520  *
5521  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5522  */
5523 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5524 
5525 /**
5526  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5527  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5528  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5529  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5530  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5531  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5532  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5533  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5534  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5535  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5536  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5537  *	for instance.
5538  */
5539 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5540 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5541 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5542 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5543 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5544 };
5545 
5546 /**
5547  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5548  *
5549  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5550  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5551  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5552  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5553  *
5554  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5555  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5556  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5557  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5558  */
5559 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5560 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5561 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5562 				  void *data);
5563 
5564 /**
5565  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5566  *
5567  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5568  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5569  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5570  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5571  * be used.
5572  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5573  *
5574  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5575  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5576  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5577  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5578  */
5579 static inline void
5580 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5581 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5582 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5583 				    void *data)
5584 {
5585 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5586 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5587 				     iterator, data);
5588 }
5589 
5590 /**
5591  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5592  *
5593  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5594  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5595  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5596  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5597  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5598  *
5599  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5600  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5601  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5602  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5603  */
5604 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5605 						u32 iter_flags,
5606 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5607 						    u8 *mac,
5608 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5609 						void *data);
5610 
5611 /**
5612  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5613  *
5614  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5615  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5616  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5617  * The driver must not call this with a lock held that it can also take in
5618  * response to callbacks from mac80211, and it must not call this within
5619  * callbacks made by mac80211 - both would result in deadlocks.
5620  *
5621  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5622  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5623  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5624  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5625  */
5626 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5627 					     u32 iter_flags,
5628 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5629 						u8 *mac,
5630 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5631 					     void *data);
5632 
5633 /**
5634  * ieee80211_iterate_stations - iterate stations
5635  *
5636  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5637  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5638  * function for them.
5639  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5640  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic can be used.
5641  *
5642  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5643  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5644  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5645  */
5646 void ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5647 				void (*iterator)(void *data,
5648 						 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5649 				void *data);
5650 
5651 /**
5652  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5653  *
5654  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5655  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5656  * function for them.
5657  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5658  *
5659  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5660  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5661  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5662  */
5663 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5664 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5665 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5666 				       void *data);
5667 /**
5668  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5669  *
5670  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5671  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5672  *
5673  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5674  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5675  */
5676 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5677 
5678 /**
5679  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5680  *
5681  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5682  * workqueue.
5683  *
5684  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5685  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5686  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5687  */
5688 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5689 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5690 				  unsigned long delay);
5691 
5692 /**
5693  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5694  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5695  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5696  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5697  *
5698  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5699  *
5700  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5701  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5702  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5703  */
5704 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5705 				  u16 timeout);
5706 
5707 /**
5708  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5709  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5710  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5711  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5712  *
5713  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5714  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5715  * from any context.
5716  */
5717 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5718 				      u16 tid);
5719 
5720 /**
5721  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5722  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5723  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5724  *
5725  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5726  *
5727  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5728  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5729  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5730  */
5731 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5732 
5733 /**
5734  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5735  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5736  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5737  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5738  *
5739  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5740  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5741  * can be called from any context.
5742  */
5743 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5744 				     u16 tid);
5745 
5746 /**
5747  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5748  *
5749  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5750  * @addr: station's address
5751  *
5752  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5753  *
5754  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5755  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5756  */
5757 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5758 					 const u8 *addr);
5759 
5760 /**
5761  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5762  *
5763  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5764  * @addr: remote station's address
5765  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5766  *
5767  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5768  *
5769  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5770  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5771  *
5772  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5773  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5774  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5775  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5776  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5777  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5778  *      is not reliable.
5779  *
5780  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5781  */
5782 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5783 					       const u8 *addr,
5784 					       const u8 *localaddr);
5785 
5786 /**
5787  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5788  * @hw: the hardware
5789  * @pubsta: the station
5790  * @block: whether to block or unblock
5791  *
5792  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5793  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5794  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5795  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5796  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5797  *
5798  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5799  * manner.
5800  *
5801  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5802  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5803  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5804  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5805  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5806  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5807  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5808  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5809  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5810  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5811  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5812  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5813  * woke up while blocked or not.
5814  */
5815 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5816 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5817 
5818 /**
5819  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5820  * @pubsta: the station
5821  *
5822  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5823  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5824  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5825  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5826  *
5827  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5828  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5829  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5830  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5831  *
5832  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5833  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5834  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5835  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
5836  */
5837 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5838 
5839 /**
5840  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5841  * @pubsta: the station
5842  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5843  *
5844  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5845  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5846  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5847  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5848  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5849  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5850  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5851  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5852  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5853  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5854  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5855  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5856  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5857  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5858  */
5859 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5860 
5861 /**
5862  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
5863  *
5864  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
5865  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
5866  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
5867  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
5868  *
5869  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
5870  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
5871  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
5872  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
5873  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
5874  * attempts.
5875  *
5876  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
5877  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
5878  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
5879  * them to 0.
5880  *
5881  * @pubsta: the station
5882  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
5883  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
5884  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
5885  */
5886 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5887 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
5888 
5889 /**
5890  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
5891  *
5892  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5893  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5894  *
5895  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
5896  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
5897  */
5898 bool
5899 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5900 
5901 /**
5902  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5903  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5904  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5905  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5906  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5907  *
5908  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5909  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5910  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5911  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5912  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5913  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5914  *
5915  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5916  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5917  * set_key callback.
5918  */
5919 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5920 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5921 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5922 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5923 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5924 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5925 				      void *data),
5926 			 void *iter_data);
5927 
5928 /**
5929  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5930  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5931  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5932  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5933  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5934  *
5935  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5936  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5937  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5938  * in removal process will be skipped.
5939  *
5940  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5941  * and thus iter must be atomic.
5942  */
5943 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5944 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5945 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5946 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5947 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5948 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5949 					  void *data),
5950 			     void *iter_data);
5951 
5952 /**
5953  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5954  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5955  * @iter: iterator function
5956  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5957  *
5958  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5959  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5960  * places while calling into the driver.
5961  *
5962  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5963  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5964  * removed.
5965  *
5966  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5967  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5968  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5969  * or not.
5970  */
5971 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5972 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5973 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5974 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5975 		     void *data),
5976 	void *iter_data);
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5980  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5981  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5982  *
5983  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5984  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5985  * information. This function must only be called from within the
5986  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5987  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5988  * %NULL.
5989  *
5990  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5991  */
5992 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5993 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5994 
5995 /**
5996  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5997  *
5998  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5999  *
6000  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6001  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6002  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6003  */
6004 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6005 
6006 /**
6007  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6008  *
6009  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6010  *
6011  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6012  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6013  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6014  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6015  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6016  *
6017  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6018  * without connection recovery attempts.
6019  */
6020 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6021 
6022 /**
6023  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6024  *
6025  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6026  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6027  *
6028  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6029  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6030  */
6031 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6032 
6033 /**
6034  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6035  *
6036  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6037  *
6038  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6039  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6040  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6041  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6042  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6043  *
6044  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6045  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6046  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6047  * disconnect normally later.
6048  *
6049  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6050  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6051  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6052  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6053  */
6054 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6055 
6056 /**
6057  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6058  *	rssi threshold triggered
6059  *
6060  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6061  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6062  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6063  * @gfp: context flags
6064  *
6065  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6066  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6067  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6068  */
6069 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6070 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6071 			       s32 rssi_level,
6072 			       gfp_t gfp);
6073 
6074 /**
6075  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6076  *
6077  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6078  * @gfp: context flags
6079  */
6080 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6081 
6082 /**
6083  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6084  *
6085  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6086  */
6087 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6088 
6089 /**
6090  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6091  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6092  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6093  *
6094  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6095  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6096  */
6097 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6098 
6099 /**
6100  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6101  * @vif &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6102  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6103  *
6104  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6105  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6106  * a deauth frame in this case.
6107  */
6108 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6109 					 bool block_tx);
6110 
6111 /**
6112  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6113  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6114  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6115  *
6116  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6117  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6118  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6119  */
6120 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6121 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6122 
6123 /**
6124  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6125  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6126  */
6127 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6128 
6129 /**
6130  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6131  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6132  */
6133 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6134 
6135 /**
6136  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6137  *
6138  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6139  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6140  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6141  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6142  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6143  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6144  *
6145  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6146  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6147  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6148  */
6149 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6150 				  const u8 *addr);
6151 
6152 /**
6153  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6154  * @pubsta: station struct
6155  * @tid: the session's TID
6156  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6157  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6158  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6159  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6160  *
6161  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6162  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6163  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6164  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6165  */
6166 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6167 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6168 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6169 
6170 /**
6171  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6172  *
6173  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6174  * buffer.
6175  *
6176  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6177  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6178  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6179  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6180  */
6181 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6182 
6183 /**
6184  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6185  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6186  * @addr: station mac address
6187  * @tid: the rx tid
6188  */
6189 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6190 				 unsigned int tid);
6191 
6192 /**
6193  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6194  *
6195  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6196  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6197  * reordering.
6198  *
6199  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6200  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6201  *
6202  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6203  * @addr: station mac address
6204  * @tid: the rx tid
6205  */
6206 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6207 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6208 {
6209 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6210 		return;
6211 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6212 }
6213 
6214 /**
6215  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6216  *
6217  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6218  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6219  * reordering.
6220  *
6221  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6222  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6223  *
6224  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6225  * @addr: station mac address
6226  * @tid: the rx tid
6227  */
6228 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6229 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6230 {
6231 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6232 		return;
6233 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6234 }
6235 
6236 /**
6237  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6238  *
6239  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6240  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6241  *
6242  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6243  *
6244  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6245  * @addr: station mac address
6246  * @tid: the rx tid
6247  */
6248 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6249 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6250 
6251 /* Rate control API */
6252 
6253 /**
6254  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6255  *
6256  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6257  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6258  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6259  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6260  *	to be filled in
6261  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6262  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6263  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6264  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6265  *	RTS threshold
6266  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6267  *	if the selected rate supports it
6268  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6269  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6270  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6271  */
6272 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6273 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6274 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6275 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6276 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6277 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6278 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6279 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6280 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6281 	bool bss;
6282 };
6283 
6284 /**
6285  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6286  */
6287 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6288 	/**
6289 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6290 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6291 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6292 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6293 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6294 	 */
6295 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6296 	/**
6297 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6298 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6299 	 */
6300 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6301 };
6302 
6303 struct rate_control_ops {
6304 	unsigned long capa;
6305 	const char *name;
6306 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6307 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6308 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6309 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6310 
6311 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6312 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6313 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6314 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6315 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6316 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6317 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6318 			    u32 changed);
6319 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6320 			 void *priv_sta);
6321 
6322 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6323 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6324 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6325 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6326 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6327 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6328 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6329 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6330 
6331 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6332 				struct dentry *dir);
6333 
6334 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6335 };
6336 
6337 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6338 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6339 				 int index)
6340 {
6341 	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6342 }
6343 
6344 static inline s8
6345 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6346 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6347 {
6348 	int i;
6349 
6350 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6351 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6352 			return i;
6353 
6354 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6355 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6356 
6357 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6358 	return 0;
6359 }
6360 
6361 static inline
6362 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6363 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6364 {
6365 	unsigned int i;
6366 
6367 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6368 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6369 			return true;
6370 	return false;
6371 }
6372 
6373 /**
6374  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6375  *
6376  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6377  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6378  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6379  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6380  *
6381  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6382  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6383  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6384  */
6385 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6386 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6387 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6388 
6389 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6390 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6391 
6392 static inline bool
6393 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6394 {
6395 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6396 }
6397 
6398 static inline bool
6399 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6400 {
6401 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6402 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6403 }
6404 
6405 static inline bool
6406 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6407 {
6408 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6409 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6410 }
6411 
6412 static inline bool
6413 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6414 {
6415 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6416 }
6417 
6418 static inline bool
6419 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6420 {
6421 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6422 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6423 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6424 }
6425 
6426 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6427 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6428 {
6429 	if (p2p) {
6430 		switch (type) {
6431 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6432 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6433 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6434 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6435 		default:
6436 			break;
6437 		}
6438 	}
6439 	return type;
6440 }
6441 
6442 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6443 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6444 {
6445 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6446 }
6447 
6448 /**
6449  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6450  *
6451  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6452  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6453  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6454  *
6455  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6456  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6457  * matching GroupId management frame.
6458  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6459  */
6460 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6461 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6462 
6463 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6464 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6465 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6466 
6467 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6468 
6469 /**
6470  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6471  *
6472  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6473  *
6474  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6475  *
6476  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6477  * applicable.
6478  */
6479 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6480 
6481 /**
6482  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6483  * @vif: virtual interface
6484  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6485  * @gfp: allocation flags
6486  *
6487  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6488  */
6489 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6490 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6491 				    gfp_t gfp);
6492 
6493 /**
6494  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6495  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6496  * @vif: virtual interface
6497  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6498  * @band: the band to transmit on
6499  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6500  *
6501  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6502  */
6503 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6504 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6505 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6506 
6507 /**
6508  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6509  *				 of injected frames.
6510  *
6511  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6512  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6513  * of the skb before calling this function.
6514  *
6515  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6516  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6517  */
6518 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6519 				 struct net_device *dev);
6520 
6521 /**
6522  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6523  *
6524  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6525  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6526  *
6527  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6528  *
6529  * private:
6530  *
6531  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6532  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6533  */
6534 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6535 	u32 next_tsf;
6536 	bool has_next_tsf;
6537 
6538 	u8 absent;
6539 
6540 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6541 	struct {
6542 		u32 start;
6543 		u32 duration;
6544 		u32 interval;
6545 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6546 };
6547 
6548 /**
6549  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6550  *
6551  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6552  * @data: NoA tracking data
6553  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6554  *
6555  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6556  */
6557 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6558 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6559 
6560 /**
6561  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6562  *
6563  * @data: NoA tracking data
6564  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6565  */
6566 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6567 
6568 /**
6569  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6570  * @vif: virtual interface
6571  * @peer: the peer's destination address
6572  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6573  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6574  * @gfp: allocation flags
6575  *
6576  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6577  */
6578 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6579 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6580 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6581 
6582 /**
6583  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6584  *
6585  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6586  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6587  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6588  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6589  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6590  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6591  *
6592  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6593  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6594  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6595  *
6596  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6597  * @tid: the TID to reserve
6598  *
6599  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6600  */
6601 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6602 
6603 /**
6604  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6605  *
6606  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6607  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6608  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6609  *
6610  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6611  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6612  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6613  *
6614  * @sta: the station
6615  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6616  */
6617 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6618 
6619 /**
6620  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6621  *
6622  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6623  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6624  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6625  *
6626  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6627  *
6628  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6629  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6630  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6631  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6632  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6633  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6634  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6635  *
6636  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6637  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6638  */
6639 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6640 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6641 
6642 /**
6643  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6644  * (in process context)
6645  *
6646  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6647  * (internally disables bottom halves).
6648  *
6649  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6650  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6651  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6652  */
6653 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6654 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6655 {
6656 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6657 
6658 	local_bh_disable();
6659 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6660 	local_bh_enable();
6661 
6662 	return skb;
6663 }
6664 
6665 /**
6666  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6667  *
6668  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6669  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6670  *
6671  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6672  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6673  * driver has finished scheduling it.
6674  */
6675 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6676 
6677 /**
6678  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
6679  *
6680  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6681  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
6682  *
6683  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
6684  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
6685  */
6686 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6687 
6688 /* (deprecated) */
6689 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
6690 {
6691 }
6692 
6693 /**
6694  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
6695  *
6696  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6697  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6698  *
6699  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
6700  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
6701  *
6702  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
6703  * this TXQ internally.
6704  */
6705 void ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6706 
6707 /**
6708  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
6709  *
6710  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6711  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6712  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
6713  *
6714  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
6715  * internally.
6716  */
6717 void ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6718 			  bool force);
6719 
6720 /**
6721  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
6722  *
6723  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
6724  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
6725  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
6726  * next_txq().
6727  *
6728  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
6729  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
6730  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
6731  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
6732  * again.
6733  *
6734  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
6735  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
6736  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
6737  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
6738  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
6739  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
6740  *
6741  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6742  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6743  */
6744 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6745 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6746 
6747 /**
6748  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
6749  *
6750  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
6751  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
6752  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
6753  *
6754  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6755  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
6756  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
6757  */
6758 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6759 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
6760 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
6761 
6762 /**
6763  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
6764  *
6765  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
6766  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6767  *
6768  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6769  * @inst_id: the local instance id
6770  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
6771  * @gfp: allocation flags
6772  */
6773 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6774 				   u8 inst_id,
6775 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
6776 				   gfp_t gfp);
6777 
6778 /**
6779  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
6780  *
6781  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
6782  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
6783  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6784  *
6785  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6786  * @match: match event information
6787  * @gfp: allocation flags
6788  */
6789 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6790 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
6791 			      gfp_t gfp);
6792 
6793 /**
6794  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
6795  *
6796  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6797  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
6798  *
6799  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6800  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
6801  *          information.
6802  * @len: frame length in bytes
6803  */
6804 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6805 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
6806 			      int len);
6807 
6808 /**
6809  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
6810  *
6811  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6812  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
6813  *
6814  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6815  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6816  * @len: frame length in bytes
6817  */
6818 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6819 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
6820 			      int len);
6821 /**
6822  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
6823  *
6824  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
6825  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
6826  * hardware or firmware.
6827  *
6828  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6829  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
6830  */
6831 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
6832 
6833 /**
6834  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
6835  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6836  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6837  *
6838  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
6839  *
6840  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
6841  */
6842 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6843 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6844 
6845 /**
6846  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
6847  *	probe response template.
6848  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6849  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6850  *
6851  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
6852  *
6853  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
6854  */
6855 struct sk_buff *
6856 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6857 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6858 
6859 /**
6860  * ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
6861  * collision.
6862  *
6863  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6864  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
6865  *	aware of.
6866  */
6867 void
6868 ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6869 				       u64 color_bitmap);
6870 
6871 /**
6872  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
6873  *
6874  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
6875  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
6876  *
6877  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
6878  */
6879 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
6880 {
6881 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
6882 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
6883 
6884 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
6885 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
6886 }
6887 
6888 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
6889